blob: 906fd08828d9a3a00109712eb332c61674c55023 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
680/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
681///
682/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
683/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
684/// found template arguments.
685static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
686 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
687 TemplateName TName =
688 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
689
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000690 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
691 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000692 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
693 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
694 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000695 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000696
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000698}
699
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000700/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
701/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
702/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000704 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
705 return false;
706
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
708 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
709 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
710 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
711 if (!BaseRT) return false;
712
713 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000714 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000715 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
716 return false;
717 }
718
719 return true;
720}
721
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000722/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
723/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
724static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000725 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000726
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000727 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
728 if (!DC) return true;
729
730 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
731 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
732
733 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
734 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
735
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736 return false;
737}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000738
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000893 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
926 if (isInstance)
927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000928 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 else
930 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
939 }
940 }
941
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000942 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000944 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (!R.empty()) {
946 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
947 if (SS.isEmpty())
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
949 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
950 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
951 else
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
953 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
954 << SS.getRange()
955 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
956 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
957 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
958 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
959 << ND->getDeclName();
960
961 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
962 return false;
963 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000964
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
966 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
967 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
968 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
969 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
970 // to recover well anyway.
971 if (SS.isEmpty())
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
973 else
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
975 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
976 << SS.getRange();
977
978 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
979 return true;
980 }
981 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000982 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000986 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000988 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
989 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 return true;
991 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000993 }
994
995 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
996 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
997 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
998 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
999 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1000 << SS.getRange();
1001 return true;
1002 }
1003
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001004 // Give up, we can't recover.
1005 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1006 return true;
1007}
1008
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001009Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001010 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1012 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1013 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1014 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1015 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1016
1017 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001018 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001019
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001020 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001021
1022 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1023 DeclarationName Name;
1024 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1025 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001026 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1027 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001030
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001031 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1032 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001033 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1034 // (note: handled after lookup)
1035 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1036 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1037 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1039 // names a dependent type.
1040 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1041 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001042 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1043 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1044 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001046 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001047 TemplateArgs);
1048 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001049
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050 // Perform the required lookup.
1051 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1052 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001053 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1054 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1055 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1056 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1057 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001058 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1059 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1060 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001062 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1063 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001064
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1066 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001067 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1068 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001069 if (E.isInvalid())
1070 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001071
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1073 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001074 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001075 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001076
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1078 return ExprError();
1079
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001080 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1081 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001083
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001085 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1087 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1088 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1089 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1090 }
1091
1092 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1093 // call, diagnose the problem.
1094 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001095 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001096 return ExprError();
1097
1098 assert(!R.empty() &&
1099 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001100
1101 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1102 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001103 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001104 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1105 R.clear();
1106 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1107 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1108 return move(E);
1109 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001110 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001111 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001112
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1114 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1115
1116 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 // Warn about constructs like:
1118 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1119 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001120 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1121 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001122 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001123 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001126 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001127 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1128 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001129 break;
1130 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001132 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1133 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001134 }
1135 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001137 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1138 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1139 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1140 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1141 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1142 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001145
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001146 QualType T = Func->getType();
1147 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001148 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001149 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1150 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 }
1153 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001154
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001155 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1156 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1157 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1158 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1159 // class member access expression.
1160 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1161 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001162 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001164 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1165 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001166 }
1167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (TemplateArgs)
1169 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001170
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1172}
1173
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001174/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1175Sema::OwningExprResult
1176Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1177 LookupResult &R,
1178 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1179 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1180 case IMA_Instance:
1181 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1182
1183 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1184 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1185 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1186 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1187
1188 case IMA_Mixed:
1189 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1190 case IMA_Unresolved:
1191 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1192
1193 case IMA_Static:
1194 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1195 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1196 if (TemplateArgs)
1197 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1198 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1199
1200 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1201 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1202 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1203 return ExprError();
1204 }
1205
1206 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1207 return ExprError();
1208}
1209
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001210/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1211/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1212/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1213/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001214Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001215Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 DeclarationName Name,
1217 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1218 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001219 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1221
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001222 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001223 return ExprError();
1224
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001225 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1226 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1227
1228 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1229 return ExprError();
1230
1231 if (R.empty()) {
1232 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1233 return ExprError();
1234 }
1235
1236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1237}
1238
1239/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1240/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1241/// additional lookup.
1242///
1243/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1244/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1245///
1246/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1247Sema::OwningExprResult
1248Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001249 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001251 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001252
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1254 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1255 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1256 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1257 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1258
1259 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1260 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1261 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001262 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001263
1264 bool LookForIvars;
1265 if (Lookup.empty())
1266 LookForIvars = true;
1267 else if (IsClassMethod)
1268 LookForIvars = false;
1269 else
1270 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1271 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001272 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001274 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1276 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1277 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1278 if (IsClassMethod)
1279 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1280 << IV->getDeclName());
1281
1282 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1283 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1284 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1285 return ExprError();
1286
1287 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1289 return ExprError();
1290
1291 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1292 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1293 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1294 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1295
1296 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1297 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1298 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1299 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001300 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001301 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1302 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1303 SelfName, false, false);
1304 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1305 return Owned(new (Context)
1306 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1307 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1308 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001310 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1313 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1314 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1315 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1316 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1317 }
1318 }
1319
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001320 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1321 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1322 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1323 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1324 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1325 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1326 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1327 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1328 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1333 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001334}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001335
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1337///
1338/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1339///
1340/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1341/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1342/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1343/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1344///
1345/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1346/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1347/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1348/// the class declaring the member.
1349///
1350/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1351/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1352/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001353bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001354Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1355 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001356 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001357 NamedDecl *Member) {
1358 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1359 if (!RD)
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 QualType DestRecordType;
1363 QualType DestType;
1364 QualType FromRecordType;
1365 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1366 bool PointerConversions = false;
1367 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1368 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001369
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001370 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1371 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1372 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1373 PointerConversions = true;
1374 } else {
1375 DestType = DestRecordType;
1376 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001377 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001378 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1379 if (Method->isStatic())
1380 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001381
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001382 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1383 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1386 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1387 PointerConversions = true;
1388 } else {
1389 FromRecordType = FromType;
1390 DestType = DestRecordType;
1391 }
1392 } else {
1393 // No conversion necessary.
1394 return false;
1395 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001396
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001397 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1398 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1401 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001404 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1405 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1406
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001407 bool isLvalue
1408 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1409
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 // class name.
1413 //
1414 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1415 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1416 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1417 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1418 //
1419 // class Base { public: int x; };
1420 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1421 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1422 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1423 //
1424 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1425 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1426 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1427 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001429 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1430 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1431 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1432
1433 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1434
1435 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1436 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1437 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1438 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001441 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001445 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001446 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001447 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448
1449 FromType = QType;
1450 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1451
1452 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1453 // we're done.
1454 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1455 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 }
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1462 // down to the using declaration's type.
1463 //
1464 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1465 // class ever has member declarations.
1466 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1467 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1468 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1469 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1470
1471 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1472 // conversion is non-trivial.
1473 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1474 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001477 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001479
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 QualType UType = URecordType;
1481 if (PointerConversions)
1482 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001483 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001484 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 FromType = UType;
1486 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1487 }
1488
1489 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1490 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1491 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001493
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001501 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001503}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001504
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001505/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001506static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001507 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001508 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1509 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001510 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1511 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1512 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001513 if (SS.isSet()) {
1514 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1515 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001517
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001519 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001520}
1521
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001522/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1523/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1524/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1525/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001526Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1528 LookupResult &R,
1529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1530 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1532
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001533 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001534
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001535 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1536 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001537 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001539 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001540 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001542
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001543 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1544 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001545 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1546 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001547 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1548 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001549 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1550 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1551 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1552 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001553 }
1554
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001555 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1556 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1557 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001558 SS,
1559 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1560 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001561}
1562
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001563bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001564 const LookupResult &R,
1565 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001566 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1567 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1568 return false;
1569
1570 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001572 return false;
1573
1574 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001575 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001576 return false;
1577
1578 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1579 // normal lookup:
1580 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1581 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1582
1583 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1584 // -- a declaration of a class member
1585 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1586 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001587 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001588 return false;
1589
1590 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1591 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1592 // using-declaration
1593 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1594 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1595 // turn off ADL anyway).
1596 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1597 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1598 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1599 return false;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1603 // template
1604 // And also for builtin functions.
1605 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1606 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1607
1608 // But also builtin functions.
1609 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1610 return false;
1611 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1612 return false;
1613 }
1614
1615 return true;
1616}
1617
1618
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001619/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1620/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1621/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1622/// will in fact be used.
1623static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1624 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1625 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1626 return true;
1627 }
1628
1629 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1630 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1631 return true;
1632 }
1633
1634 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1635 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1636 return true;
1637 }
1638
1639 return false;
1640}
1641
1642Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001644 LookupResult &R,
1645 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001646 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1647 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001648 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001650
1651 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1652 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1653 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001654 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1655 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656 return ExprError();
1657
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001658 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1659 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1660 // we've picked a target.
1661 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1662
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 bool Dependent
1664 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001666 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1668 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001669 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001670 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1671 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001672
1673 return Owned(ULE);
1674}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001675
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676
1677/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1681 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001682 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1683 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684
1685 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1686 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001687
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001688 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1689 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1690 // a template argument list.
1691 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1692 << Template << SS.getRange();
1693 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1694 return ExprError();
1695 }
1696
1697 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1698 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1699 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001701 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001702 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001703 return ExprError();
1704 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001705
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001706 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1707 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1708 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1709 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001710 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001711 return ExprError();
1712
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001713 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1714 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001715 return ExprError();
1716
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001717 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1718 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1719 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1720 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001721 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001722 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1723 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1724 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001725 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001726 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001727 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1728 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1729 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1730 return ExprError();
1731 }
1732
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001733 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001734 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1735 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1736 return ExprError();
1737 }
1738
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001739 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001740 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001741 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001742 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001743 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001744 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1745 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001746 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001747
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001748 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001749 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001750 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001751 }
1752 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1753 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001754
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001755 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001756}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001757
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1759 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001760 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001761
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001762 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001763 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001764 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1765 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1766 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001767 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001768
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001769 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1770 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001772 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1773 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001774 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001775 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001776 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001778 QualType ResTy;
1779 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1780 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1781 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001782 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001784 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001785 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001786 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1787 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001788 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001789}
1790
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001792 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001793 bool Invalid = false;
1794 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1795 if (Invalid)
1796 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001798 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1799 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001800 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001802
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001803 QualType Ty;
1804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1805 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1806 else if (Literal.isWide())
1807 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001808 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1809 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001810 else
1811 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001812
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001813 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1814 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001815 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001816}
1817
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1819 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001820 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1821 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001822 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001823 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001825 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001826 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001827
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001828 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001829 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1830 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001831 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001833 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001834 bool Invalid = false;
1835 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1836 if (Invalid)
1837 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001839 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001840 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001841 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842 return ExprError();
1843
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001844 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001846 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001847 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001848 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001849 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001850 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001851 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001852 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001853 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001854
1855 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1856
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001857 using llvm::APFloat;
1858 APFloat Val(Format);
1859
1860 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001861
1862 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1863 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1864 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1865 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001866 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001867 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001869 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001870 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1871 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001872 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001873 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1874 }
1875
1876 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1877 << Ty
1878 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1879 }
1880
1881 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001882 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001884 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001886 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001887 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001888
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001889 // long long is a C99 feature.
1890 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001891 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001892 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1893
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001894 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001895 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001897 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1898 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1899 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001900 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1901 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001902 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001903 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001904 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1905 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001907 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1908 // be an unsigned int.
1909 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1910
1911 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001912 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001913 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1914 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001917 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1918 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1919 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1920 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001923 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001924 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001932 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1933 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1934 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1935 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001936 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001937 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941 }
1942
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001947 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1948 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1949 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1950 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001951 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001952 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 }
1956 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1959 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1967 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001968 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001969 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001970 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1973 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001975 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
1977 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001978}
1979
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1981 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001982 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001984 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001985}
1986
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00001987/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00001988/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001989bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001990 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1991 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1992 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001993 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1994 return false;
1995
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001996 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1997 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1998 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1999 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2000 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2001 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2002
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002003 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002004 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002005 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002006 if (isSizeof)
2007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2008 return false;
2009 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002011 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002012 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2014 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002015 return false;
2016 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002017
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002018 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002019 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2020 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002021 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002024 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002026 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2027 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002030 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2032 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2033 return true;
2034 }
2035
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002037}
2038
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002039bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2040 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2041 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002042
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002044 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2045 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002046
2047 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2048 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2049 return false;
2050
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002051 if (E->getBitField()) {
2052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002054 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002055
2056 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2057 // bit-field.
2058 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002059 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002060 return false;
2061
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2063}
2064
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002065/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002067Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002068 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002069 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002070 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002071 return ExprError();
2072
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002073 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002074
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002075 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2076 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2077 return ExprError();
2078
2079 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002080 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002081 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2082 R.getEnd()));
2083}
2084
2085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2086/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087Action::OwningExprResult
2088Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2090 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2091 bool isInvalid = false;
2092 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2093 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2094 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2095 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002096 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002097 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2098 isInvalid = true;
2099 } else {
2100 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2101 }
2102
2103 if (isInvalid)
2104 return ExprError();
2105
2106 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2107 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2108 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2109 R.getEnd()));
2110}
2111
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002112/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2113/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2114/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002115Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2117 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002118 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002119 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002120
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002121 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002122 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2123 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2124 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002127 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2128 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2129 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2130
2131 if (Result.isInvalid())
2132 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2133
2134 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002135}
2136
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002137QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2139 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002141 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002142 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002143 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002145 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2146 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2147 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002149 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2151 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002152 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002153}
2154
2155
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002156
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002157Action::OwningExprResult
2158Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2159 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002160 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2161 switch (Kind) {
2162 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2163 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2164 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2165 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002166
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002167 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002168}
2169
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170Action::OwningExprResult
2171Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2172 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002173 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2174 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2175
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002176 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2177 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002180 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2181 Base.release();
2182 Idx.release();
2183 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2184 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2185 }
2186
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002189 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2190 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2191 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002192 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002193 }
2194
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002195 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2196}
2197
2198
2199Action::OwningExprResult
2200Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2201 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2202 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2203 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2204
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002205 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002206 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2207 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2208 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002209
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002211
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002212 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002213 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002214 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002215 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2217 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002218 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2219 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2220 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2221 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002222 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2224 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002226 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002227 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2229 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002232 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002233 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002237 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002238 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2239 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2241 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002242 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002245
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2247 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002248 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2249 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002250 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002251 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2252 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2253 // force the promotion here.
2254 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2255 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002256 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2257 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002258 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2259
2260 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2261 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002262 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2264 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2265 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2266 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002267 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2268 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2270
2271 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2272 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002273 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002274 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002275 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2276 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002278 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002279 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2280 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002281 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2282 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002283
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002284 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002285 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2286 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002287 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2288
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002289 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2291 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002292 // incomplete types are not object types.
2293 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2294 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2295 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2296 return ExprError();
2297 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002299 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002300 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002301 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002303 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002305 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002306 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2308 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2309 return ExprError();
2310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002312 Base.release();
2313 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002314 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002315 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002316}
2317
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002318QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002319CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002321 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002322 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2323 // see FIXME there.
2324 //
2325 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2326 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002327 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002328
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002329 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002330 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002331
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002333 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2334 // to be selected.
2335 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002337 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2338 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002339 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340
2341 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2342 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2345 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002347 do
2348 compStr++;
2349 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002350 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002351 do
2352 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002354 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002357 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2358 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2360 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002361 return QualType();
2362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2365 // operates on.
2366 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002367 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368
2369 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002370 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371
2372 while (*compStr) {
2373 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2374 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2375 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2376 return QualType();
2377 }
2378 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002380
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002382 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002383 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002385 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002386 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002387 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388 if (HexSwizzle)
2389 CompSize--;
2390
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 if (CompSize == 1)
2392 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002394 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002396 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2397 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2398 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2399 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002400 }
2401 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402}
2403
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002404static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002406 const Selector &Sel,
2407 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002409 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002410 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002411 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002414 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2415 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002417 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002418 return D;
2419 }
2420 return 0;
2421}
2422
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002423static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002424 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002425 const Selector &Sel,
2426 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2428 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002429 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002431 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 GDecl = PD;
2433 break;
2434 }
2435 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002436 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 GDecl = OMD;
2438 break;
2439 }
2440 }
2441 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2444 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002446 if (GDecl)
2447 return GDecl;
2448 }
2449 }
2450 return GDecl;
2451}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002452
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002453Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002454Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2455 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002456 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2457 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2458 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2459 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2460 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2461
2462 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2463 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2464 //
2465 // T* t;
2466 // t.f;
2467 //
2468 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2469 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2470 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2471 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2474 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002475 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478 return ExprError();
2479 }
2480 }
2481
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002482 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002483 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484
2485 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2486 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002487 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2489 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2490 SS.getRange(),
2491 FirstQualifierInScope,
2492 Name, NameLoc,
2493 TemplateArgs));
2494}
2495
2496/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2497/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2498/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2499static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2500 Expr *BaseExpr,
2501 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002502 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002503 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002504 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2505 // diagnostics.
2506 if (!BaseExpr)
2507 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002509 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2510 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511}
2512
2513// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2514// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2515// type. The restriction here is:
2516//
2517// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2518// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2519// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2520//
2521// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2522// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2523// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2524// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2525bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2526 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002527 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002529 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2530 if (!BaseRT) {
2531 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2532 // dependent.
2533 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2534 return false;
2535 }
2536 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002537
2538 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002539 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2540 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002541 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002543
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002544 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2545 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2546 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2547 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2548
2549 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2550 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2551
2552 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2553 return false;
2554 }
2555
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002556 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 return true;
2558}
2559
2560static bool
2561LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2562 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002563 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2565 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002566 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002567 << BaseRange))
2568 return true;
2569
2570 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2571 if (SS.isSet()) {
2572 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2573 // nested-name-specifier.
2574 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2575
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002576 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002577 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2578 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2579 return true;
2580 }
2581
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002582 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002583
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2585 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2586 << DC << SS.getRange();
2587 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002588 }
2589 }
2590
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002591 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2592 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002593
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002594 if (!R.empty())
2595 return false;
2596
2597 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2598 // for typos.
2599 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002600 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002601 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002602 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2603 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2604 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002605 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2606 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002607 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2608 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2609 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002610 return false;
2611 } else {
2612 R.clear();
2613 }
2614
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002615 return false;
2616}
2617
2618Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002619Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002621 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002622 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2623 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2624 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2625 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2626
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002627 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2628 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002629 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2631 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2632 Name, NameLoc,
2633 TemplateArgs);
2634
2635 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637 // Implicit member accesses.
2638 if (!Base) {
2639 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2640 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2641 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2642 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2643 OpLoc, SS))
2644 return ExprError();
2645
2646 // Explicit member accesses.
2647 } else {
2648 OwningExprResult Result =
2649 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002650 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651
2652 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2653 Owned(Base);
2654 return ExprError();
2655 }
2656
2657 if (Result.get())
2658 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002659
2660 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2661 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662 }
2663
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002664 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002665 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2666 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667}
2668
2669Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2671 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2672 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002673 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002674 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002675 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2676 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002677 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002678 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002679 if (IsArrow) {
2680 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2681 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2682 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002683 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002684
2685 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2686 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2687 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2688 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2689
2690 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002691 return ExprError();
2692
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002693 if (R.empty()) {
2694 // Rederive where we looked up.
2695 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2696 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2697 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002698
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002699 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002700 << MemberName << DC
2701 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702 return ExprError();
2703 }
2704
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002705 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2706 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2707 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2708 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2709 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2710 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2711 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2712 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2713 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2714 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002715 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002716 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002717 return ExprError();
2718
2719 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2720 // result.
2721 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002723 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002725 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002727 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2728 // pick a member.
2729 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2730
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002731 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2732 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2733 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2735 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002736 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2737 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002738 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002739
2740 return Owned(MemExpr);
2741 }
2742
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002743 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002744 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002745 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2746
2747 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2748
2749 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2750 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2751 // error cases.
2752 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2753 return ExprError();
2754
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2756 if (!BaseExpr) {
2757 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002758 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002759 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2760
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002761 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2762 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2763 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2764 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 }
2766
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2768 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2769 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2770 // explicitly qualified.
2771 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2772 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2773 }
2774
2775 // Check the use of this member.
2776 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2777 Owned(BaseExpr);
2778 return ExprError();
2779 }
2780
2781 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2782 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2783 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002784 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2785 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002786 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2787 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2788
2789 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2790 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2791 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2792 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2793 else {
2794 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2795 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2796 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2797
2798 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2799 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2800
2801 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2802 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2803 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2804 }
2805
2806 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002807 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808 return ExprError();
2809 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002810 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811 }
2812
2813 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2814 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2815 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002816 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2818 }
2819
2820 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2821 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2822 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002823 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824 MemberFn->getType()));
2825 }
2826
2827 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2828 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2829 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002830 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 }
2832
2833 Owned(BaseExpr);
2834
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002835 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002837 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2838 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2839 else
2840 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2841 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002843 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2844 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002845 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002846 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002847}
2848
2849/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2850/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2851/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2852/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2853/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2854/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2855/// an ordinary member expression.
2856///
2857/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2858/// fixed for ObjC++.
2859Sema::OwningExprResult
2860Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002861 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002862 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002864 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002865
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002866 // Perform default conversions.
2867 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002868
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002869 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002870 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2871
2872 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2873 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002874
2875 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002877 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2878 // call, and continue on.
2879 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2880 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2881 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2882 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2883 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002884 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2885 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002886 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2887 ->isRecordType()))) {
2888 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2889 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2890 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002891 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002892
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002893 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002894 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002895 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2896 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002897 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002898
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002899 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2900 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2901 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2902 }
2903 }
2904 }
2905
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002906 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2907 // use that.
2908 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002909 if (IsArrow) {
2910 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2911 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2912 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002913 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002914 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002915 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2916 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002917 }
2918 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002919 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2920 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2921 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2922 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002923 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002924 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002925 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002926
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002927 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2928 // use that.
2929 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2930 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2931 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2932 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2933 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2934 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2935 }
2936 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002937
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002938 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002939
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002940 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002941 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002942 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2943 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2944 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2945 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2946 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2947 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2948 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2949 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2950 // Check the use of this method.
2951 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2952 return ExprError();
2953 }
2954 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2955 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2956 Selector SetterSel =
2957 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2958 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2959 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2960 if (!Setter) {
2961 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2962 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002963 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002964 }
2965 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2966 if (!Setter)
2967 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002968
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002969 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2970 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002971
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002972 if (Getter || Setter) {
2973 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002974
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002975 if (Getter)
2976 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2977 else
2978 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2979 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2980 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002981 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002982 PType,
2983 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2984 }
2985 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2986 << MemberName << BaseType);
2987 }
2988 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002989
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002990 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2991 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2992 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002993 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002995
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002996 if (IsArrow) {
2997 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002998 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002999 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3000 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003001 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3002 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3003 // struct MyRecord foo;
3004 // foo->bar
3005 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3006 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3007 // by now.
3008 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3009 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003010 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003011 IsArrow = false;
3012 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3014 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3015 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003016 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003017 } else {
3018 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3019 // type *foo;
3020 // foo.bar
3021 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3022 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3023 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3024 // the appropriate pointer type
3025 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3026 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3027 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3028 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3029 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003030 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003031 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3032 IsArrow = true;
3033 }
3034 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003036
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003037 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003038 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003039 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3040 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003041 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003042 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003043 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003044
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003045 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3046 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003048 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003049 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003050 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3051 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3052 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3053 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003054 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3055
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003056 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003057 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003058
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003059 if (!IV) {
3060 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3061 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3062 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003063 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003064 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003065 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003066 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3067 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003068 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3069 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003070 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003071 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003072 }
3073 }
3074
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003075 if (IV) {
3076 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3077 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3078 // error cases.
3079 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003081
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003082 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3083 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3084 return ExprError();
3085 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3086 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3087 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3088 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3089 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3090 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3091 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3092 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3093 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3094 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3095 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3096 // AST for a function decl.
3097 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003098 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003099 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3100 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3101 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3102 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3103 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3104 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003105
3106 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3107 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003108 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003109 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003111 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3112 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003113 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003114 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003115 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003116
3117 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3118 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003119 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003120 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003121 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003122 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003123 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003124 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003125 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003126 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3128 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003129 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003130 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003131
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003132 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003133 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003134 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3135 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3136 // Check the use of this declaration
3137 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3138 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003139
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003140 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3141 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3142 }
3143 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3144 // Check the use of this method.
3145 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3146 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003147
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003148 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003149 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3150 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3151 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003152 }
3153 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003154
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003155 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003156 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003157 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003158
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003159 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3160 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003161 if (!IsArrow)
3162 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3163 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003164 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003165
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003166 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003167 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003168 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3169 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003170 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003171 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003172 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003173
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003174 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003175 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003176 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003177 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3178 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003179 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003180 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003181 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003182 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003183
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003184 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3185 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3186
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003187 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003188}
3189
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003190/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3191/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3192/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3193/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3194/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3195///
3196/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3197/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3198/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3199/// only be called
3200/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3201/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3202/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3203Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3204 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3205 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003206 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003207 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3208 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3209 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3210 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3211 return ExprError();
3212
3213 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3214
3215 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3216 DeclarationName Name;
3217 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3218 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3219 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3220 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3221
3222 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3223
3224 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3225 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3226 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3227
3228 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3229 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3230
3231 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3232 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003233 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3234 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003235 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003236 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3237 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3238 Name, NameLoc,
3239 TemplateArgs);
3240 } else {
3241 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3242 if (TemplateArgs) {
3243 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3244 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003245
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003246 // Re-derive the naming class.
3247 if (SS.isSet()) {
3248 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3249 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3250 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3251 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3252 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3253 } else {
3254 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3255 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3256 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3257 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3258 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3259 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260 } else {
3261 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003262 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003263
3264 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3265 Owned(Base);
3266 return ExprError();
3267 }
3268
3269 if (Result.get()) {
3270 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3271 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3272 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3273 // call now.
3274 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3275 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003276 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003277
3278 return move(Result);
3279 }
3280 }
3281
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003282 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003283 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3284 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003285 }
3286
3287 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003288}
3289
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003290Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3291 FunctionDecl *FD,
3292 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3293 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3294 Diag (CallLoc,
3295 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3296 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003297 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003298 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3299 } else {
3300 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3301 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3302
3303 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003304 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3305 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003306
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3308 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003309 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003310
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003311 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003312 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003313 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003314
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003315 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3316 InitializedEntity Entity
3317 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3318 InitializationKind Kind
3319 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3320 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3321 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3322
3323 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003324 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003325 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3326 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003327 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003328
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003329 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003330 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003331 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003332 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003333
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003334 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3335 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3336 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003337 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3338 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003339 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3340 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003341 }
3342
3343 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003344 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003345}
3346
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003347/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3348/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3349/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3350/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3351/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3352/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003353bool
3354Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003355 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003356 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003357 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3358 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003359 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003360 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3361 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003362 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003363
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003364 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3365 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3366 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3367 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3368 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003369 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003370 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003371 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003372 }
3373
3374 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3375 // them.
3376 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3377 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3378 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3379 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003380 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003381 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003382 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3383 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3384 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003385 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003386 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003387 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003388 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003389 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003390 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003391 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3392 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3393 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3394 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3395 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003396 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003397 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003398 if (Invalid)
3399 return true;
3400 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3401 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3402 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003403
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003404 return false;
3405}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003406
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003407bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3408 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3409 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3410 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3411 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3412 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003413 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003414 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3415 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3416 bool Invalid = false;
3417 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3418 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3419 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3420 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003421 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003422 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003423 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003424
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003425 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003426 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3427 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003428
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003429 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3430 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003431 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003432 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003433 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003434
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003435 // Pass the argument
3436 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3437 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3438 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003439
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003440
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003441 InitializedEntity Entity =
3442 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3443 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3444 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3445 SourceLocation(),
3446 Owned(Arg));
3447 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3448 return true;
3449
3450 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003451 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003452 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003453
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003454 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003455 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003456 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3457 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003458
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003460 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003461 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003462 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003463
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003464 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003465 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003467 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003469 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003470 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003471 }
3472 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003473 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003474}
3475
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003476/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003477/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3478/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003479Action::OwningExprResult
3480Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3481 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003483 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003484
3485 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3486 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003487
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003488 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003489 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003490 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003491
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003492 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003493 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3494 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3495 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3496 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3497 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003498 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003499 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3500 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003501
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003502 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3503 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003505 NumArgs = 0;
3506 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003507
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003508 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3509 RParenLoc));
3510 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003512 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003513 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003514 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3515 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003516 bool Dependent = false;
3517 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3518 Dependent = true;
3519 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3520 Dependent = true;
3521
3522 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003523 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003524 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3525
3526 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3527 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3528 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3529 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3530
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003531 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3532
3533 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3534 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3535 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3536 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3537 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3538 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3539 // method template.
3540 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003541 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3542 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003543 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003544
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003545 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3546 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003547 }
3548
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003549 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003550 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003551 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003552 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003553 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3554 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003555 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003556
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003557 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003558 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003559 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3560 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003561 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3562 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003563 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
3565 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3566 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003567 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3568 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003569
3570 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3571 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003572 TheCall.get(), 0))
3573 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003574
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003575 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003576 RParenLoc))
3577 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003578
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003579 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3580 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003581 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003582 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3583 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003584 }
3585 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 }
3587
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003588 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003589 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003590 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003591
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003592 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003593 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3594 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003595 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003596 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003597 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003598
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003599 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3600 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3601 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3602
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003603 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3604}
3605
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003606/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3607/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003608/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3609/// block-pointer type.
3610///
3611/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3612Sema::OwningExprResult
3613Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3614 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3615 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3616 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3617 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3618
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003619 // Promote the function operand.
3620 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3621
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003622 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3623 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003624 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3625 Args, NumArgs,
3626 Context.BoolTy,
3627 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003628
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003629 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3630 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3631 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3632 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003633 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003634 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003635 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3636 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003637 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003638 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003639 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003640 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003641 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003642 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003643 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3644 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3645
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003646 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003647 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003648 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3649 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003650 return ExprError();
3651
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003652 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003653 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003654
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003655 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003656 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003657 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003658 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003659 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003660 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003661
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003662 if (FDecl) {
3663 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3664 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3665 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003666 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003667 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003668 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003669 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3670 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3671 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3672 }
3673 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003674 }
3675
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003676 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003677 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3678 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3679 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003680 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3681 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003682 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3683 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003684 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003685 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003686 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003687 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003688
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003689 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3690 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003691 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3692 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003693
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003694 // Check for sentinels
3695 if (NDecl)
3696 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003698 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003699 if (FDecl) {
3700 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3701 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003702
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003703 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003704 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3705 } else if (NDecl) {
3706 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3707 return ExprError();
3708 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003709
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003710 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003711}
3712
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003713Action::OwningExprResult
3714Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3715 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003716 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003717 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003718 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003719
3720 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3721 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3722 if (!TInfo)
3723 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3724
3725 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3726}
3727
3728Action::OwningExprResult
3729Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3730 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3731 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003732 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003733
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003734 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003735 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003736 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3737 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003738 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3739 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003740 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003741 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003742 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003743 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003744
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003745 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003746 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003747 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003748 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003749 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003750 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3751 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3752 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3753 &literalType);
3754 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003755 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003756 InitExpr.release();
3757 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003758
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003759 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003760 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003761 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003762 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003763 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003764
3765 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003766
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003767 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003768 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003769}
3770
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003771Action::OwningExprResult
3772Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003773 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3774 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3775 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003776
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003777 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003778 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003779
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003780 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3781 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003782 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003783 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003784}
3785
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003786static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3787 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003788 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003789 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3790
3791 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3792 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003793 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3794 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003795 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003796 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3797 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3798 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003799
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003800 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3801 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3802 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3803 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3804 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3805 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3806 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3807 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003808
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003809 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3810 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3811 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3812 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3813 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3814 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003815
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003816 // FIXME: Assert here.
3817 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3818 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3819}
3820
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003821/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003822bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003823 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003824 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003825 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003826 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003827 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3828 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003829
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003830 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003831
3832 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3833 // type needs to be scalar.
3834 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3835 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003836 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3837 return false;
3838 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003839
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003840 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003841 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003842 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3843 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003844 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003845 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3846 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003847 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003848 return false;
3849 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003850
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003851 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003852 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003853 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003854 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003855 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003856 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003857 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003858 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003859 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3860 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3861 break;
3862 }
3863 }
3864 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3865 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3866 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003867 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003868 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003869 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003871 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3872 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3873 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3874 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003875
3876 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003877 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003878 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3879 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003880 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003882
3883 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003884 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003885
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003886 if (castType->isVectorType())
3887 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3888 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3889 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3890
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003891 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3892 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003893
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003894 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003895 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3896 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3897 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3898 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3899 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3900 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3901 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3902 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3903 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3904 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003905 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906
3907 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003908 return false;
3909}
3910
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003911bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3912 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003913 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003914
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003915 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003916 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003917 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003918 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003919 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003920 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003921 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003922 } else
3923 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003924 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003925 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003926
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003927 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003928 return false;
3929}
3930
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003931bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003932 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003933 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003934
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003935 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003936
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003937 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3938 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003939 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3940 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3941 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3942 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003943 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003944 return false;
3945 }
3946
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003947 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003948 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3949 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003950 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3951 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3952 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3953 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003954
3955 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3956 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3957 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003958
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003959 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003960 return false;
3961}
3962
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003963Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003964Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003965 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3966 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3967 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003968
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003969 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3970 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3971 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003972 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003973
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003974 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003975 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003976 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003977 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3978 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003979
3980 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3981}
3982
3983Action::OwningExprResult
3984Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3985 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3986 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3987
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003988 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003989 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003990 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003991 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003992 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003993
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003994 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003995 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003996 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003997 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003998}
3999
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004000/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4001/// of comma binary operators.
4002Action::OwningExprResult
4003Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4004 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4005 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4006 if (!E)
4007 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004008
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004009 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004011 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4012 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4013 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004014
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004015 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4016}
4017
4018Action::OwningExprResult
4019Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4020 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004021 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004022 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004023 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004024
4025 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004026 // then handle it as such.
4027 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4028 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4029 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4030 return ExprError();
4031 }
4032
4033 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4034 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4035 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4036
4037 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4038 // braces instead of the original commas.
4039 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004040 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4041 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004042 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4043 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004044 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004045 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004046 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004047 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4048 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004049 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004050 }
4051}
4052
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004053Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004055 MultiExprArg Val,
4056 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004057 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4058 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004059 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4060 Expr *expr;
4061 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4062 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4063 else
4064 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004065 return Owned(expr);
4066}
4067
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004068/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4069/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004070/// C99 6.5.15
4071QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4072 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004073 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4074 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4075 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4076
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004077 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4078 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4079 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4080 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4081 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4082 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004083
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004084 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004085 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4086 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4087 << CondTy;
4088 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004089 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004090
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004091 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004092 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4093 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004094
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004095 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4096 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004097 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4098 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4099 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004100 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004101
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004102 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4103 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004104 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4105 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004106 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004107 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004108 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004109 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004110 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004111 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004112
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004113 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004114 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004115 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4116 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4117 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4118 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4119 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4120 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4121 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004122 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4123 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004124 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004125 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004126 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4127 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004128 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004129 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004130 // promote the null to a pointer.
4131 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004132 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004133 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004134 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004135 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004136 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004137 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004138 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004139
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004140 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4141 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4142 QuestionLoc);
4143 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4144 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004145
4146
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004147 // Handle block pointer types.
4148 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4149 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4150 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4151 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004152 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4153 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004154 return destType;
4155 }
4156 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004157 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004158 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004159 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004160 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4161 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4162 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004163 return LHSTy;
4164 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004165 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004166 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4167 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004168
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004169 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4170 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004171 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004172 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004173 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4174 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4175 // to get a consistent AST.
4176 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004177 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4178 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004179 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004180 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004181 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004182 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4183 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004184 return LHSTy;
4185 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004186
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004187 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4188 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4189 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004190 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4191 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004192
4193 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4194 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4195 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004196 QualType destPointee
4197 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004198 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004199 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4200 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4201 // Promote to void*.
4202 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004203 return destType;
4204 }
4205 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004206 QualType destPointee
4207 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004208 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004209 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004210 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004211 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004212 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004213 return destType;
4214 }
4215
4216 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4217 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4218 return LHSTy;
4219 }
4220 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4221 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4222 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4223 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4224 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4225 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4226 // to get a consistent AST.
4227 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004228 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4229 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004230 return incompatTy;
4231 }
4232 // The pointer types are compatible.
4233 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4234 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4235 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4236 // type.
4237 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4238 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004239 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4240 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004241 return LHSTy;
4242 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004243
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004244 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4245 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4246 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4247 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004249 return RHSTy;
4250 }
4251 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4252 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4253 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004254 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 return LHSTy;
4256 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004257
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004258 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004259 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4260 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004261 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004262}
4263
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004264/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4265/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4266QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4267 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4268 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4269 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004270
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004271 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4272 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4273 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4274 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4275 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4276 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4277 return LHSTy;
4278 }
4279 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4280 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4281 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4282 return RHSTy;
4283 }
4284 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4285 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4286 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4287 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4288 return LHSTy;
4289 }
4290 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4291 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4292 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4293 return RHSTy;
4294 }
4295 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4296 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4297 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4298 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4299 return LHSTy;
4300 }
4301 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4302 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4303 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4304 return RHSTy;
4305 }
4306 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4307 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004308
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004309 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4310 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4311 return LHSTy;
4312 }
4313 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4314 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4315 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004316
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004317 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4318 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4319 // type. This allows
4320 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4321 // where B is a subclass of A.
4322 //
4323 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4324 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4325 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4326 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004327
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004328 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4329 // It could return the composite type.
4330 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4331 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4332 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4333 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4334 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4335 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4336 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4337 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4338 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4339 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4340 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4341 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4342 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4343 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004344 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004345 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4346 ;
4347 else {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4350 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4351 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4352 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4353 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4354 return incompatTy;
4355 }
4356 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4357 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4358 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4359 return compositeType;
4360 }
4361 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4362 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4363 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4364 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4365 QualType destPointee
4366 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4367 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4368 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4369 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4370 // Promote to void*.
4371 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4372 return destType;
4373 }
4374 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4375 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4376 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4377 QualType destPointee
4378 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4379 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4380 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4381 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4382 // Promote to void*.
4383 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4384 return destType;
4385 }
4386 return QualType();
4387}
4388
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004389/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004390/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004391Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4392 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4393 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4394 ExprArg RHS) {
4395 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4396 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004397
4398 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4399 // was the condition.
4400 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4401 if (isLHSNull)
4402 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004403
4404 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004405 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004406 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004407 return ExprError();
4408
4409 Cond.release();
4410 LHS.release();
4411 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004412 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004413 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004414 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004415}
4416
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004417// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004418// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004419// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4420// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4421// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004422Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004423Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004424 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004425
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004426 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4427 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4428 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4429 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4430 return Compatible;
4431 }
4432
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004433 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004434 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4435 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004436
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004437 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004438 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4439 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004440
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004441 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004442
4443 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4444 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4445 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004446 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004447 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004448 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004449
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004450 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4451 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004452 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004453 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004454 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004455 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004456
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004457 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004458 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4459 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004460 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004461
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004462 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004463 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004464 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004465
4466 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004467 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4468 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004469 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004470 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004471 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004472 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4473 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4474 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4475 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4476 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4477 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004478 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004479 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004480 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004481 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004482
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004483 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004484 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004485 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004486 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004487
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004488 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4489 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4490 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4491 // warning can be disabled.
4492 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4493 return ConvTy;
4494 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4495 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004496
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004497 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4498 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4499 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4500 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4501 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4502 do {
4503 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4504 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004505
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004506 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4507 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4508 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004509
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004510 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004511 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004512 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004513
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004514 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004515 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004516 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004517 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004518}
4519
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004520/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4521/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4522/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4523// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004524Sema::AssignConvertType
4525Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004526 QualType rhsType) {
4527 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004528
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004529 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004530 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4531 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004533 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4534 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4535 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004536
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004537 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004539 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004540 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004541 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004543 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4544 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4545 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4546 }
4547 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004549 return ConvTy;
4550}
4551
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004552/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4553/// for assignment compatibility.
4554Sema::AssignConvertType
4555Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004556 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4557 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004558 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4559 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004560 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004561 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004562 }
4563 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4564 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004565 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4566 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004567 return IncompatiblePointer;
4568 return Compatible;
4569 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004570 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004571 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004572 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004573 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4574 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4575 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4576 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4577 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4578 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004579
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004580 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4581 return Compatible;
4582 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4583 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004584 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004585}
4586
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004587/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4588/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004589/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4590///
4591/// int a, *pint;
4592/// short *pshort;
4593/// struct foo *pfoo;
4594///
4595/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4596/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4597/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4598/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4599///
4600/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004601/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004602///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004603Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004604Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004605 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4606 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004607 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4608 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004609
4610 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004611 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004612
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004613 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4614 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4615 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4616 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4617 return Compatible;
4618 }
4619
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004620 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4621 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4622 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4623 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4624 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4625 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4626 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004627 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004628 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004629 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004630 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004631 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004632 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4633 // to the same ExtVector type.
4634 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4635 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4636 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4637 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4638 return Compatible;
4639 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004640
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004641 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004642 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004643 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004644 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004645 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4646 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004647 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004648 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004649 }
4650 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004651 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004652
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004653 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4654 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004655 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004656
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004657 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004658 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004659 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004660
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004661 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004662 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004663
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004664 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004665 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004666 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4667 return Compatible;
4668 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004669 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004670 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4671 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004672 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004673
4674 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004675 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004676 return Compatible;
4677 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004678 return Incompatible;
4679 }
4680
4681 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4682 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004683 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004684
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004685 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004686 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004687 return Compatible;
4688
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004689 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4690 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004691
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004692 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004693 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004694 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004695 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004696 return Incompatible;
4697 }
4698
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004699 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4700 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4701 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004702
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004703 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004705 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4706 return Compatible;
4707 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004708 }
4709 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004710 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004711 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004712 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004713 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4714 return Compatible;
4715 }
4716 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4717 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4718 return Compatible;
4719 return Incompatible;
4720 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004721 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004722 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004723 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4724 return Compatible;
4725
4726 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004727 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004728
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004729 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004730 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004731
4732 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004733 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004734 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004735 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004736 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004737 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4738 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4739 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4740 return Compatible;
4741
4742 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4743 return PointerToInt;
4744
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004745 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004746 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004747 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4748 return Compatible;
4749 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004750 }
4751 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004752 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004753 return Compatible;
4754 return Incompatible;
4755 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004756
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004757 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004758 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004759 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004760 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004761 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004762}
4763
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004764/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4765/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004766static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004767 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4768 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4769 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004770 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004771 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004772 SourceLocation());
4773 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4774 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4775
4776 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4777 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004778 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004779 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004780 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004781}
4782
4783Sema::AssignConvertType
4784Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4785 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4786
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004787 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004788 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4789 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004790 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004791 return Incompatible;
4792
4793 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4794 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4795 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4796 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004797 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4798 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004799 it != itend; ++it) {
4800 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4801 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4802 // 1) void pointer
4803 // 2) null pointer constant
4804 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004805 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004806 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004807 InitField = *it;
4808 break;
4809 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004810
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004811 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004812 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004813 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004814 InitField = *it;
4815 break;
4816 }
4817 }
4818
4819 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4820 == Compatible) {
4821 InitField = *it;
4822 break;
4823 }
4824 }
4825
4826 if (!InitField)
4827 return Incompatible;
4828
4829 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4830 return Compatible;
4831}
4832
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004833Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004834Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004835 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4836 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4837 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4838 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4839 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004840 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004841 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004842 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004843 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004844 }
4845
4846 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4847 // structures.
4848 }
4849
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004850 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4851 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004852 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4853 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004854 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004855 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004856 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004857 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004858 return Compatible;
4859 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004860
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004861 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004862 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004863 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004864 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004865 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004866 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004867 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004868 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004869
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004870 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4871 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004872
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004873 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4874 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004875 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4876 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4877 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4878 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004879 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004880 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4881 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004882 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004883}
4884
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004885QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004886 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004887 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004888 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004889 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004890}
4891
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004892QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004893 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004894 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004895 QualType lhsType =
4896 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4897 QualType rhsType =
4898 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004899
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004900 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004901 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004902 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004903
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004904 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4905 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004906 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4907 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004908 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4909 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004910 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004911 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004912 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4913 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4914 return lhsType;
4915 }
4916
4917 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4918 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004919 }
4920 }
4921 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004922
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004923 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4924 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4925 bool swapped = false;
4926 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4927 swapped = true;
4928 std::swap(rex, lex);
4929 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4930 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004931
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004932 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004933 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004934 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4935 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4936 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004937 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004938 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4939 return lhsType;
4940 }
4941 }
4942 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4943 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4944 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004945 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004946 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4947 return lhsType;
4948 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004949 }
4950 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004951
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004952 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004953 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004954 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004955 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004956 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004957}
4958
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004959QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4960 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004961 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004962 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004963
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004964 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004965
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004966 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4967 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4968 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004969
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004970 // Check for division by zero.
4971 if (isDiv &&
4972 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004973 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004974 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004975
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004976 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004977}
4978
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004979QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004980 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004981 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4982 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4983 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4984 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4985 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004986
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004987 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004989 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4990 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004991
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004992 // Check for remainder by zero.
4993 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004994 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4995 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004996
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004997 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00004998}
4999
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005000QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005001 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005002 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5003 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5004 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5005 return compType;
5006 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005007
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005008 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005009
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005010 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005011 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5012 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5013 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005014 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005015 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005016
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005017 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5018 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005019 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005020 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5021
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005022 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005023
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005024 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005025 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005026
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005027 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5028 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005029 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5030 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005031 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005032 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005033 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005034
5035 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5036 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5037 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005038 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005039 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5040 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5041 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5042 return QualType();
5043 }
5044
5045 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5046 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5047 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005048 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005049 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005050 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005051 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005052 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5053 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005054 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5055 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005056 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005057 return QualType();
5058 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005059 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005060 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005061 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5062 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5063 return QualType();
5064 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005065
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005066 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005067 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5068 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5069 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5070 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5071 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005072 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005073 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5074 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005075 return PExp->getType();
5076 }
5077 }
5078
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005079 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005080}
5081
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005082// C99 6.5.6
5083QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005084 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5085 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5086 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5087 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5088 return compType;
5089 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005090
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005092
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005093 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005094
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005095 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005096 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5097 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005098 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005099 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005100 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005101
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005102 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005103 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005104 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005105
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005106 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005107
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005108 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5109 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5110 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5111 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5112 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5113 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5114 return QualType();
5115 }
5116
5117 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5118 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5119 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5120 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5121 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005122 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005123 return QualType();
5124 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005125
5126 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5127 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5128 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005129 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005130 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005131 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005132 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005133 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005134
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005135 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005136 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005137 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5138 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5139 return QualType();
5140 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005141
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005142 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005143 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5144 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5145 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5146 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5147 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5148 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005149 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005150 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5151
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005152 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005153 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005155
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005156 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005157 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005158 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005159
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005160 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5161 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5162 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5163 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5164 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5165 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5166 return QualType();
5167 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005168
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005169 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5170 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5171 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5172 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005173 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005174 return QualType();
5175 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005176
5177 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5178 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5179 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5180 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5181 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005182 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5183 << rex->getSourceRange()
5184 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005185 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005186
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5188 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5189 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5190 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5191 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5192 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5193 return QualType();
5194 }
5195 } else {
5196 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5197 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5198 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5199 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5200 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5201 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5202 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5203 return QualType();
5204 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005205 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005206
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005207 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5208 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5209 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5210 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5211 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005212 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005213 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005214
5215 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005216 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5217 }
5218 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005219
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005220 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005221}
5222
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005223// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005224QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005225 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005226 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5227 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005228 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005229
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005230 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5231 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5232 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5233
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005234 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5235 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005236 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5237 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5238 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5239 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5240 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005241 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005242 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005243 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005244
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005245 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005246
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005247 // Sanity-check shift operands
5248 llvm::APSInt Right;
5249 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005250 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5251 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005252 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005253 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5254 else {
5255 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5256 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5257 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5258 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5259 }
5260 }
5261
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005262 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005263 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005264}
5265
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005266// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005267QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005268 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5269 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5270
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005271 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005272 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005273 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005274
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005275 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005276 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5277 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5278 else {
5279 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5280 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5281 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005282 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5283 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005284
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005285 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5286 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005287 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5288 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5289 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005290 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005291 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005292 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5293 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5294 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5295 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005296 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5297 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005298 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005299
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005300 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5301 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5302 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5303 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005304
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005305 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5306 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005307 Expr *literalString = 0;
5308 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005309 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005310 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005311 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005312 literalString = lex;
5313 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005314 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5315 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005316 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005317 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005318 literalString = rex;
5319 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5320 }
5321
5322 if (literalString) {
5323 std::string resultComparison;
5324 switch (Opc) {
5325 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5326 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5327 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5328 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5329 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5330 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5331 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5332 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005333
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005334 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5335 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5336 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005337 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005338 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005339 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005340
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005341 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005342 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005343
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005344 if (isRelational) {
5345 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005346 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005347 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005348 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005349 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005350 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005351
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005352 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005353 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005354 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005355
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005356 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005357 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005358 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005359 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005360
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005361 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5362 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5363 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005364 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005365 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005366 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005367 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005368 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005370 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005371 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5372 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005373 if (!isRelational &&
5374 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5375 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5376 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5377 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5378 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5379 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5380 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5381 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5382 return ResultTy;
5383 }
5384 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005385 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5386 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5387 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5388 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5389 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5390 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005391 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005392 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005393 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005394 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005395 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005396 if (T.isNull()) {
5397 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5398 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5399 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005400 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005401 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005402 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005403 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005404 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005405 }
5406
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005407 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5408 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005409 return ResultTy;
5410 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005411 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5412 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5413 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5414 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5415 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5416 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5417 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5418 }
5419 } else if (!isRelational &&
5420 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5421 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5422 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5423 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5424 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5425 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5426 }
5427 } else {
5428 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005429 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005430 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005431 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005432 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005433 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005434 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005435 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005436
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005437 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005439 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005440 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005441 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5442 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005443 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005444 return ResultTy;
5445 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005446 if (LHSIsNull &&
5447 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5448 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005449 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005450 return ResultTy;
5451 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005452
5453 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005454 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005455 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5456 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5458 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5459 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5460 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5461 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5462 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5463 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5464 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005465 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005466 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005467 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005468 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005469 if (T.isNull()) {
5470 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005471 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005472 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005473 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005474 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005475 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005476 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005477 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005480 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5481 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005482 return ResultTy;
5483 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005484
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005485 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005486 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5487 return ResultTy;
5488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005490 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005491 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005492 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5493 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005494
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005495 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005496 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005497 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005498 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005499 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005500 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005501 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005502 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005503 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005504 if (!isRelational
5505 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5506 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005507 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005508 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005509 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005510 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005511 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5512 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5513 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005514 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005515 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005516 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005517 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005518
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005519 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005520 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005521 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5522 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005523 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005524 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005525 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005526 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005527
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005528 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5529 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005530 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005531 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005532 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005533 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005534 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005535 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005536 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005537 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005538 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5539 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005540 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005541 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005542 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005543 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005544 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005545 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5546 if (RHSIsNull) {
5547 if (isRelational)
5548 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5549 } else if (isRelational)
5550 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5551 else
5552 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005553
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005554 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005555 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005556 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005557 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005558 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005559 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005560 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005561 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005562 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5563 if (LHSIsNull) {
5564 if (isRelational)
5565 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5566 } else if (isRelational)
5567 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5568 else
5569 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005570
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005571 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005572 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005573 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005574 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005575 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005576 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005577 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005578 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005579 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5580 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005581 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005582 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005583 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005584 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5585 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005586 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005587 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005588 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005589 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005590}
5591
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005592/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005593/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005594/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5595/// types.
5596QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005597 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005598 bool isRelational) {
5599 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5600 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005601 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005602 if (vType.isNull())
5603 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005604
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005605 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5606 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005607
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005608 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5609 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5610 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5611 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5612 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5613 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5614 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005615 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005616 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005617
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005618 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5619 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5620 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005621 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005622 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005623
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005624 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5625 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5626 // elements for floating point vectors.
5627 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5628 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005629
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005630 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005631 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005632 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005633 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005634 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005635 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5636
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005637 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005638 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005639 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5640}
5641
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005642inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005644 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005645 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005646
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005647 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005648
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005649 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005650 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005651 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005652}
5653
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005654inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005655 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005656 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5657 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5658 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005659
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005660 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5661 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005662
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005663 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005664 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005665
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005666 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5667 // non-overloadable operands.
5668
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005669 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5670 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005671 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5672 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5673 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005674 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005675
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005676 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5677 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5678 // The result is a bool.
5679 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005680}
5681
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005682/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5683/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5684/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5685///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005687 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5688 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5689 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5690 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005691 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005692 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5693 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5694 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5695 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005696 }
5697 }
5698 return false;
5699}
5700
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005701/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5702/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5703static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005704 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005705 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005706 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005707 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5708 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005709 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5710 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005711
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005712 unsigned Diag = 0;
5713 bool NeedType = false;
5714 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005715 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005716 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005717 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5718 NeedType = true;
5719 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005721 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5722 NeedType = true;
5723 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005724 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005725 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5726 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005727 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5728 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005729 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005730 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5731 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005732 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5733 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005734 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5735 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005736 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005737 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005738 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005739 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005740 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5741 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005742 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005743 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5744 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005745 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5746 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5747 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005748 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5749 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5750 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005751 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5752 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5753 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005754 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005755
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005756 SourceRange Assign;
5757 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5758 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005759 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005760 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005761 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005762 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005763 return true;
5764}
5765
5766
5767
5768// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005769QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5770 SourceLocation Loc,
5771 QualType CompoundType) {
5772 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5773 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005774 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005775
5776 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5777 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005778
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005779 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005780 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005781 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005782 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005783 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5784 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5785 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005786 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005787 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005788 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005789 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005790
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005791 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5792 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5793 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005794 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005795 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5796 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5797 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5798 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5799 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005800 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005801 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005802 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5803 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5804 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005805 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5806 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005807 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5808 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5809 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005810 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005811 }
5812 } else {
5813 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005814 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005815 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005816
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005817 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005818 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005819 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005820
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005821 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5822 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005823 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005824 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5825 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005826 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005827 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005828 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005829}
5830
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005831// C99 6.5.17
5832QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005833 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005834 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5835 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5836 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005837
5838 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5839 // incomplete in C++).
5840
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005841 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005842}
5843
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005844/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5845/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005846QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005847 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005848 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5849 return Context.DependentTy;
5850
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005851 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5852 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005853
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005854 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5855 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5856 if (!isInc) {
5857 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5858 return QualType();
5859 }
5860 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5861 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5862 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005863 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005864 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5865 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005866
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005867 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005868 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005869 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5870 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5871 << Op->getSourceRange();
5872 return QualType();
5873 }
5874
5875 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005876 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005877 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005878 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5879 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5880 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5881 return QualType();
5882 }
5883
5884 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005885 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005886 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005887 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005888 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005889 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005890 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005891 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005892 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005893 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5894 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5895 return QualType();
5896 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005897 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005898 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5899 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005900 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005901 } else {
5902 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005903 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005904 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005905 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005906 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005907 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005908 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005909 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005910 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5911 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5912 // operand.
5913 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5914 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005915}
5916
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005917/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005918/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005919/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5920/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5921/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5922/// - &(x) => x
5923/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5924/// - &s.xx => s
5925/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5926/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5927/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5928/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005929static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005930 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005931 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005932 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005933 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005934 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5935 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5936 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005937 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005938 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005939 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005940 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005941 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005942 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5943 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005944 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5945 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5946 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5947 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5948 }
5949 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005950 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005951 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5952 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005953
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005954 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005955 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5956 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5957 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5958 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5959 default:
5960 return 0;
5961 }
5962 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005963 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005964 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005965 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005966 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5967 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005968 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005969 default:
5970 return 0;
5971 }
5972}
5973
5974/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005975/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005976/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005977/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00005978/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005979/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005980/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005981QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005982 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
5983 op = op->IgnoreParens();
5984
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00005985 if (op->isTypeDependent())
5986 return Context.DependentTy;
5987
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00005988 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
5989 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
5990 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
5991 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
5992 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
5993 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
5994 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
5995 }
5996 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
5997 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
5998 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005999 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006000 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006001
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006002 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6003 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6004 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6005 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6006 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6007 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6008 // branch of the if, below.
6009 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6010 << dcl;
6011 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6012
6013 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6014 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6015 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6016 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006017 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6018 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6019 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6020 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6021 if (isSFINAEContext())
6022 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006023 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006024 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006025 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006026 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006027 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006028 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6029 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006030 return QualType();
6031 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006032 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006033 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6034 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6035 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006036 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006037 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006038 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006039 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006040 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006041 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006042 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6043 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6044 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6045 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6046 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006047 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6048 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006049 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6050 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006051 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6052 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006053 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006054 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006055 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6056 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006057 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006058 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6059 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006060 return QualType();
6061 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006062 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006063 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006064 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006065 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006066 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6067 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006068 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006069 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006070 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6071 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006072 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006073 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6074 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6075 return QualType();
6076 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006077
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006078 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6079 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006080 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006081 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006082 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006083 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006084 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006085 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6086 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006087 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6088 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6089 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006090 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006091 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006092
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006093 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6094 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6095 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6096 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6097 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6098 }
6099
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006100 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006101 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006102}
6103
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006104QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006105 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6106 return Context.DependentTy;
6107
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006108 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6109 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006110
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006111 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6112 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6113 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6114 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006115 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006116 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006117
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006118 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006119 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006120
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006121 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006122 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006123 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006124}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006125
6126static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6127 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6128 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6129 switch (Kind) {
6130 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006131 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6132 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006133 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6134 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6135 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6136 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6137 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6138 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6139 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6140 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6141 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6142 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6143 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6144 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6145 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6146 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6147 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6148 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6149 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6150 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6151 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6152 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6153 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6154 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6155 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6156 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6157 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6158 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6159 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6160 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6161 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6162 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6163 }
6164 return Opc;
6165}
6166
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006167static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6168 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6169 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6170 switch (Kind) {
6171 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6172 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6173 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6174 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6175 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6176 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6177 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6178 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6179 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006180 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6181 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006182 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006183 }
6184 return Opc;
6185}
6186
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006187/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6188/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6189/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006190Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6191 unsigned Op,
6192 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006193 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006194 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006195 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6196 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6197 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006198
6199 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006200 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6201 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6202 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006203 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6204 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6205 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6206 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6207 break;
6208 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006209 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006210 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6211 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006212 break;
6213 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6214 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6215 break;
6216 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6217 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6218 break;
6219 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6220 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6221 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006222 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006223 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6224 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6225 break;
6226 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6227 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6228 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6229 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006230 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006231 break;
6232 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6233 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006234 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006235 break;
6236 case BinaryOperator::And:
6237 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6238 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6239 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6240 break;
6241 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6242 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6243 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6244 break;
6245 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6246 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006247 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6248 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006249 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6250 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6251 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006252 break;
6253 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006254 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6255 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6256 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6257 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006258 break;
6259 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006260 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6261 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6262 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006263 break;
6264 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006265 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6266 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6267 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006268 break;
6269 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6270 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006271 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6272 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6273 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6274 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006275 break;
6276 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6277 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6278 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006279 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6280 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6281 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6282 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006283 break;
6284 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6285 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6286 break;
6287 }
6288 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006289 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006290 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006291 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6292 else
6293 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006294 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6295 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006296}
6297
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006298/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6299/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006300static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6301 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006302 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6303 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6304 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006305 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006306 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6307
6308 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6309 return;
6310
6311 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6312 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6313 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006314 return;
6315 }
6316
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006317 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6318 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006319 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006320
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006321 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006322 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006323
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006324 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6325 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6326 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6327 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006328 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006329 return;
6330 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006331
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006332 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006333 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6334 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006335}
6336
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006337/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6338/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6339/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6340/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006341static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6342 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006343 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6344 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6345 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6346 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006347 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006348 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006349 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6350
6351 // Subs are not binary operators.
6352 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6353 return;
6354
6355 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6356 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006357 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6358 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006359 return;
6360
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006361 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006362 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006363 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006364 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6365 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006366 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006367 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006368 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6369 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6370 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6371 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006372 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006373 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006374 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006375 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6376 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006377 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006378 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006379 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6380 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6381 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6382 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006383}
6384
6385/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6386/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6387/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6388static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6389 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006390 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006391 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6392}
6393
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006394// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006395Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6396 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6397 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006398 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006399 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006400
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006401 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6402 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006403
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006404 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6405 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6406
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006407 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6408}
6409
6410Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6411 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6412 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006413 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006414 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006415 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6416 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6417 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6418 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6419 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006420 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006421 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006422 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6423 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6424 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006425
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006426 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6427 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006428 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006429 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006430
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006431 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006432 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006433}
6434
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006435Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006436 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006437 ExprArg InputArg) {
6438 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006439
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006440 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006441 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006442 QualType resultType;
6443 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006444 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6445 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6446 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006447
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006448 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6449 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006450 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6451 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006452 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006453 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006454 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6455 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6456 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006457 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006458 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006459 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006460 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006461 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006462 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006463 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006464 break;
6465 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6466 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006467 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6468 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006469 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6470 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006471 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6472 break;
6473 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6474 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6475 break;
6476 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6477 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6478 resultType->isPointerType())
6479 break;
6480
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006481 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6482 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006483 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006484 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6485 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006486 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6487 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006488 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6489 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6490 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006491 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006492 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006493 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006494 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6495 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006496 break;
6497 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006498 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006499 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006500 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006501 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6502 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006503 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006504 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6505 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006506 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006507 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6508 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006509 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006510 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006511 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006512 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006513 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006514 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006515 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006516 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006517 }
6518 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006519 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006520
6521 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006522 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006523}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006524
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006525Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6526 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6527 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006528 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006529 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6530 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006531 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6532 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6533 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6534 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006535 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006536 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006537 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6538 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6539 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006540
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006541 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6542 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006543
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006544 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6545}
6546
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006547// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6548Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6549 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6550 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6551}
6552
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006553/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006554Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6555 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6556 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006557 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006558 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006559
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006560 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6561 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006562 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006563 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006564
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006565 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006566 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6567 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006568}
6569
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006570Sema::OwningExprResult
6571Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6572 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6573 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006574 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6575 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6576
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006577 bool isFileScope
6578 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006579 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006580 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006581
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006582 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6583 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6584 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006585
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006586 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6587 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6588 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006589
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006590 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6591 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6592 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6593 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6594 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006595
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006596 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006597 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006598 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006599
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006600 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6601 // expressions are not lvalues.
6602
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006603 substmt.release();
6604 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006605}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006606
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006607Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6608 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006609 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6610 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006611 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6612 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006613 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006614 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006615
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006616 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6617 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6618 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006619 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006620 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6621 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6622
6623 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6624 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6625 if (!Dependent
6626 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6627 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6628 << TypeRange))
6629 return ExprError();
6630
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006631 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6632 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006633 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6634 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006635 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006636 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6637 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006638
6639 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6640 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6641 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6642 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6643 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6644 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6645 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6646 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6647 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6648 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6649 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6650 if(!AT)
6651 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6652 << CurrentType);
6653 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6654 } else
6655 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6656
6657 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6658 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6659 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6660 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6661 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6662 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6663 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6664 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6665
6666 // Record this array index.
6667 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6668 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6669 continue;
6670 }
6671
6672 // Offset of a field.
6673 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6674 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6675 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6676 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6677 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6678 continue;
6679 }
6680
6681 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6682 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6683 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6684 return ExprError();
6685
6686 // Look for the designated field.
6687 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6688 if (!RC)
6689 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6690 << CurrentType);
6691 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6692
6693 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6694 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6695 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6696 // (clause 9).
6697 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6698 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6699 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6700 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6701 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6702 << CurrentType))
6703 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6704 }
6705
6706 // Look for the field.
6707 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6708 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6709 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6710 if (!MemberDecl)
6711 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6712 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6713 OC.LocEnd));
6714
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006715 // C99 7.17p3:
6716 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6717 //
6718 // We diagnose this as an error.
6719 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6720 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6721 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6722 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6723 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6724 return ExprError();
6725 }
6726
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006727 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6728 // the base class indirections.
6729 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6730 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6731 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6732 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6733 Paths)) {
6734 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6735 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6736 B != BEnd; ++B)
6737 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6738 }
6739
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006740 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006741 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006742 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6743 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6744 unsigned n = Path.size();
6745 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6746 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6747 } else {
6748 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6749 }
6750 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6751 }
6752
6753 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6754 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6755 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6756}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006757
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6759 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6760 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6761 TypeTy *argty,
6762 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6763 unsigned NumComponents,
6764 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6765
6766 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6767 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6768 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6769 return ExprError();
6770
6771 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6772 if (!ArgTInfo)
6773 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6774
6775 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6776 RPLoc);
6777 }
6778
6779 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6780 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6781
6782 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6783
6784 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6785 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6786 // a struct/union/class.
6787 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6788 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6789
6790 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6791 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6792
6793 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6794 // the offsetof designators.
6795 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6796 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6797 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6798 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6799
6800 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6801 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6802 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6803 // a system header!
6804 if (NumComponents != 1)
6805 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6806 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6807
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006808 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006809 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006810
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006811 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6812 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6813 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006814
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006815 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6816 // leaks like a sieve.
6817 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6818 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6819 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6820 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6821 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6822 if (!AT) {
6823 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006824 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006825 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006826 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006827
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006828 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006829
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006830 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6831 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006832 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006833
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006834 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6835 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006836 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006837 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006838 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006839 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006840 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6841
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006842 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6843 OC.LocEnd);
6844 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006845 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006846
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006847 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 if (!RC) {
6849 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006850 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006851 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006852 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006853
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006854 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6855 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006856 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006857 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6858 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6859 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6861 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006862 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006863 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006865 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6866 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006867
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006868 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006869 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006870 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006871 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006872 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6873
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006874 // C99 7.17p3:
6875 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6876 //
6877 // We diagnose this as an error.
6878 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6879 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6880 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6881 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6882 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6883 return ExprError();
6884 }
6885
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006886 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6887 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006888 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006889 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006890 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006891 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006892 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6893 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006894 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6895 // doesn't matter here.
6896 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006897 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006898 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006899 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006900 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006902 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6903 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006904}
6905
6906
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006907Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6908 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6909 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006910 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6911 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6912 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006913
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006914 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006915
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006916 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6917 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6918 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6919 return ExprError();
6920 }
6921
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006922 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6923 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006924}
6925
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006926Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6927 ExprArg cond,
6928 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6929 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6930 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6931 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6932 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006933
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006934 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6935
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006936 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006937 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006938 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006939 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006940 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006941 } else {
6942 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6943 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6944 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6945 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006946 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6947 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6948 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006949
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006950 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6951 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006952 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6953 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006954 }
6955
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006956 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6957 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006958 resType, RPLoc,
6959 resType->isDependentType(),
6960 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006961}
6962
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006963//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6964// Clang Extensions.
6965//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6966
6967/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006968void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006969 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6970 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6971 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6972 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006973}
6974
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006975void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006976 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006977 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006978
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006979 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6980 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006981 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006982 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6983
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006984 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6985 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6986 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6987 return;
6988 }
6989
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006990 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6991 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006992 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6993 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006994
6995 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
6996 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006997 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006998 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006999 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007000 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007001 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7002 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007003 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007004
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007005 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007006 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007007 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7008 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7009 return;
7010 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007011
7012 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007013 return;
7014 }
7015
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007016 // Analyze arguments to block.
7017 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7018 "Not a function declarator!");
7019 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007020
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007021 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7022 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007023
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007024 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7025 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7026 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7027 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007028 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7029 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007030 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007031 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007032 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007033 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7034 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7035 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7036 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7037 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7038 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7039 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7040 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7041 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007042 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007043 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007044 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007045 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007046 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007047 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007048
7049 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7050 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7051
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007052 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007053 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7054 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7055
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007056 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007057 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7058 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7059 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7060
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007061 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007062 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007063 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007064
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007065 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007066 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007067 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007068 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007069 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007070 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7071 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007072
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007073 // Analyze the return type.
7074 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007075 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007076
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007077 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007078 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007079 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7080 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7081 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007082 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007083}
7084
7085/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7086/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7087void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007088 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007089 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007090 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007091 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007092}
7093
7094/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7095/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007096Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7097 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007098 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7099 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7100 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007101
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007102 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007103
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007104 PopDeclContext();
7105
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007106 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007107 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7108 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007109
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007110 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7111 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7112 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007113
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007114 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007115 QualType BlockTy;
7116 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007117 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007118 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007119 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007120 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007121 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007122 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007123
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007124 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007125 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007126 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007127
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007128 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007129 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007130 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007131
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007132 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007133
7134 bool Good = true;
7135 // Check goto/label use.
7136 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7137 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7138 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7139
7140 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7141 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7142 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7143 continue;
7144
7145 // Emit error.
7146 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7147 Good = false;
7148 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007149 if (!Good) {
7150 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007151 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007152 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007153
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007154 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007155 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7156 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7157 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007158
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007159 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7160 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007161 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007162 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007163}
7164
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007165Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7166 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7167 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007168 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007169 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7170 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007171
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007172 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007173
7174 // Get the va_list type
7175 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007176 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7177 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7178 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7179 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007180 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007181 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7182 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7183 } else {
7184 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7185 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007186 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007187 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007188 return ExprError();
7189 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007190
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007191 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7192 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007193 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7194 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007195 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007196 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007197
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007198 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007199 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007200
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007201 expr.release();
7202 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7203 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007204}
7205
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007206Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007207 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7208 // pointers on the target.
7209 QualType Ty;
7210 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7211 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7212 else
7213 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7214
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007215 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007216}
7217
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007218static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007219 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007220 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7221 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007222
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007223 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7224 if (!PT)
7225 return;
7226
7227 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7228 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7229 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7230 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7231 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7232 return;
7233 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007234
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007235 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7236 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7237 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7238 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007239
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007240 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007241}
7242
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007243bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7244 SourceLocation Loc,
7245 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007246 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7247 bool *Complained) {
7248 if (Complained)
7249 *Complained = false;
7250
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007251 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7252 bool isInvalid = false;
7253 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007254 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007255
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007256 switch (ConvTy) {
7257 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7258 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007259 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007260 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7261 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007262 case IntToPointer:
7263 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7264 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007265 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007266 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007267 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7268 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007269 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7270 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7271 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007272 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7273 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7274 break;
7275 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007276 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7277 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7278 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7279 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7280 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7281 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7282 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7283 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7284 // C++ semantics.
7285 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7286 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7287 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007288 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7289 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007290 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007291 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007292 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007293 case IntToBlockPointer:
7294 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7295 break;
7296 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007297 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007298 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007299 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007300 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007301 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7302 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7303 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007304 case IncompatibleVectors:
7305 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7306 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007307 case Incompatible:
7308 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7309 isInvalid = true;
7310 break;
7311 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007312
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007313 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7314 switch (Action) {
7315 case AA_Assigning:
7316 case AA_Initializing:
7317 // The destination type comes first.
7318 FirstType = DstType;
7319 SecondType = SrcType;
7320 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007321
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007322 case AA_Returning:
7323 case AA_Passing:
7324 case AA_Converting:
7325 case AA_Sending:
7326 case AA_Casting:
7327 // The source type comes first.
7328 FirstType = SrcType;
7329 SecondType = DstType;
7330 break;
7331 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007332
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007333 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007334 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007335 if (Complained)
7336 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007337 return isInvalid;
7338}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007339
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007340bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007341 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7342 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7343 if (Result)
7344 *Result = ICEResult;
7345 return false;
7346 }
7347
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007348 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7349
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007350 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007351 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7352 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7353
7354 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7355 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7356 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7357 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7358 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7359 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7360 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007361
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007362 return true;
7363 }
7364
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007365 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7366 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007367
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007368 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7369 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7370 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007371
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007372 if (Result)
7373 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7374 return false;
7375}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007376
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007377void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007378Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007379 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7380 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007381}
7382
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007383void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007384Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7385 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7386 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7387 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007388
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007389 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7390 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7391 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7392 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7393 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007394 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007395 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7396 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7397 I != IEnd; ++I)
7398 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7399 }
7400
7401 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7402 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7403 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7404 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7405 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7406 I != IEnd; ++I)
7407 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7408 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007409 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007410
7411 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7412 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7413 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7414 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007415 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007416 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7417 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7418 ExprTemporaries.end());
7419
7420 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7421 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007422}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007423
7424/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7425///
7426/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7427/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7428/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7429/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7430///
7431/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7432///
7433/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7434void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7435 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007436
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007437 if (D->isUsed())
7438 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007439
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007440 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7441 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7442 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7443 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007444 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007445 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007446 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007447 return;
7448 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007449
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007450 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7451 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007452
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007453 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7454 // an instantiation.
7455 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7456 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007457
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007458 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007459 case Unevaluated:
7460 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7461 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007462
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007463 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7464 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7465 // "used"; handle this below.
7466 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007467
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007468 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7469 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7470 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7471 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007472 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007473 return;
7474 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007475
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007476 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007477 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007478 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007479 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7480 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7481 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007482 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007483 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007484 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7485 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7486 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007487
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007488 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007489 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7490 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7491 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007492 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7493 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007494 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7495 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7496 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7497 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007498 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007499 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7500 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007501 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007502 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007503 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007504 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007505 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007506 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7507 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7508 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7509 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7510 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007511 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007512 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007513 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007514 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007515 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7516 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7517 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007518 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007519 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007520 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7521 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007522
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007523 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7524 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7525 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7526 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7527 Loc));
7528 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007529 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007530 Loc));
7531 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007532 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007533
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007534 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007535 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007536
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007537 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007538 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007539
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007540 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007541 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007542 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007543 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7544 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7545 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7546 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7547 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7548 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7549 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7550 }
7551 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007552
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007553 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007554
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007555 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007556 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007557 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007558}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007559
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007560namespace {
7561 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7562 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7563 // of when we're entering
7564 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7565 Sema &S;
7566 SourceLocation Loc;
7567
7568 public:
7569 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7570
7571 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7572
7573 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7574 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7575 };
7576}
7577
7578bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7579 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7580 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7581 }
7582
7583 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7584}
7585
7586bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7587 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7588 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7589 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7590 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7591 Args.flat_size());
7592 }
7593
7594 return false;
7595}
7596
7597void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7598 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7599 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7600}
7601
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007602/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7603/// of the program being compiled.
7604///
7605/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007606/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007607/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7608/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7609/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7610/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007611/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007612/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007613///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007614/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7615/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7616/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7617/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007618bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007619 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7620 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7621 case Unevaluated:
7622 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7623 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007624
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007625 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7626 Diag(Loc, PD);
7627 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007628
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007629 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7630 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7631 break;
7632 }
7633
7634 return false;
7635}
7636
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007637bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7638 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7639 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7640 return false;
7641
7642 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7643 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7644 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7645 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007646
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007647 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007648 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007649 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7650 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007651 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007652 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7653 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7654 return true;
7655
7656 return false;
7657}
7658
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007659// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7660// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7661void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7662 SourceLocation Loc;
7663
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007664 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7665
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007666 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7667 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7668 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7669 return;
7670
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007671 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7672 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7673 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7674 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7675
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007676 // self = [<foo> init...]
7677 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7678 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7679 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7680
7681 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7682 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7683 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7684 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7685 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007686
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007687 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7688 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7689 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7690 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7691 return;
7692
7693 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7694 } else {
7695 // Not an assignment.
7696 return;
7697 }
7698
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007699 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007700 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007701
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007702 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007703 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007704 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007705 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7706 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7707 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007708}
7709
7710bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7711 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7712
7713 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007714 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007715
7716 QualType T = E->getType();
7717
7718 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7719 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7720 return true;
7721 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7722 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7723 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7724 return true;
7725 }
7726 }
7727
7728 return false;
7729}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007730
7731Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7732 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007733 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7734 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007735 return ExprError();
7736
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007737 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7738 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7739 return ExprError();
7740 }
7741
7742 return Owned(Sub);
7743}